Fix spelling of ARM Cortex
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2407 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2408
2409 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2410 recommended as its replacement.
2411
2412 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2413 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2414
2415 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2416 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2417 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2418 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2419 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2423 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2424 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2425 is connected to the host.
2426 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2427 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2428 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2432 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2433 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2434 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2435 @itemize @minus
2436 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2437 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2438 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2439 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2440 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2441 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2442 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2443 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2444 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2445 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2446 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2447 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2448 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2449 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2450 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2451 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2453 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2454 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2455 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2456 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2457 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2458 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2459 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2460 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2461 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2462 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2463 @end itemize
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2467 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2468 default values are used.
2469 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2470 @example
2471 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2472 @end example
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2476 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2477 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2478 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2479 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2480 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2481 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2485 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2486 The default value is 1.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 For example, the interface config file for a
2490 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2491
2492 @example
2493 interface ft2232
2494 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2495 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2496 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2501 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2502 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2503 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2504 interface driver.
2505
2506 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2507 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2508 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2509
2510 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2511 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2512 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2513
2514 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2515 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2516 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2517 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2518 will be used for their customary purpose.
2519
2520 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2521 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2522 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2523 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2524
2525 @itemize @minus
2526 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2527 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2528 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2529 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2530 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2531 switching data and direction as necessary
2532 @end itemize
2533
2534 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2535 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2538 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2539 default values are used.
2540 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2541 @example
2542 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2543 @end example
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2547 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2548 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2549 during device selection.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2553 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2554 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2555 is connected to the host.
2556 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2557 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2558 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2562 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2563 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2564 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2565 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2566 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2567
2568 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2572 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2573 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2577 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2578 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2579 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2580 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2581 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2582 and initially asserted reset signals.
2583 @end deffn
2584
2585 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2586 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2587 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2588 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2589 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2590 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2591 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2592 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2593 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2594
2595 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2596 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2597 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2598 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2599 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2600 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2601
2602 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2603 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2604 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2605 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2606 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2607 are always driven by the FTDI.
2608
2609 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2610 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2611 @var{name}.
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2615 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2616 @itemize @minus
2617 @item @option{0}, drive low
2618 @item @option{1}, drive high
2619 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2620 @end itemize
2621 @end deffn
2622
2623 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2624 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2625
2626 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2627 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2628 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2629 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2632 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2633 @end itemize
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2637 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2638
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2642 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2643 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2644 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2645
2646 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2647 processors which are being simulated.
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2650 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2651 sockets instead of TCP.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2655 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2656 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2660 something like:
2661
2662 @example
2663 interface remote_bitbang
2664 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2665 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2666 @end example
2667
2668 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2669 named mysocket:
2670
2671 @example
2672 interface remote_bitbang
2673 remote_bitbang_port 0
2674 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2675 @end example
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2679 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2680 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2681 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2684 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2685 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2686 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2687 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2691 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2692 default values are used.
2693 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2694 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2695 @example
2696 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2697 @end example
2698 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2699 @example
2700 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2701 @end example
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2705 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2706 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2707 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2708 target board.
2709
2710 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2711 @example
2712 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2713 reset_config srst_only
2714 @end example
2715 @end deffn
2716
2717 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2718 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2719 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2720 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2721 @end deffn
2722
2723 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2724 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2725 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @end deffn
2729
2730 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2731 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2732 This has one driver-specific command:
2733
2734 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2735 Display either the address of the I/O port
2736 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2737 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2738 This is a write-once setting.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @end deffn
2741
2742 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2743 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2744 transports.
2745
2746 @quotation Compatibility Note
2747 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2748 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2749 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2750 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2751 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2752 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2753 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2754 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2755 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2756 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2757 @end quotation
2758
2759 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2760 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2761 states.
2762 @end deffn
2763 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2764 Display free device internal memory.
2765 @end deffn
2766 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2767 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2768 command version.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2771 Display the device configuration.
2772 @end deffn
2773 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2774 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2775 power state.
2776 @end deffn
2777 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2778 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2781 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2782 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2783 IP configuration.
2784 @end deffn
2785 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2786 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2787 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2788 @end deffn
2789 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2790 Reset the current configuration.
2791 @end deffn
2792 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2793 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2794 @end deffn
2795 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2796 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2797 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2798 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2799 instead.
2800
2801 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2802 @end deffn
2803 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2804 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2805 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2806
2807 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2812 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2813 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2814 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2815 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2816
2817 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2818 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2819 This is a write-once setting.
2820 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2821
2822 @itemize @minus
2823 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2824 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2825 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2826 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2827 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2828 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2829 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2830 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2831 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2832 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2833 some versions of
2834 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2835 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2836 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2837 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2838 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2839 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2840 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2841 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2842 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2843 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2844 @end itemize
2845 @end deffn
2846
2847 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2848 Display either the address of the I/O port
2849 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2850 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2851 This is a write-once setting.
2852
2853 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2854 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2855 you may encounter a problem.
2856 @end deffn
2857
2858 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2859 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2860 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2861 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2862 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2863 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2864
2865 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2866 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2867 @quotation Tip
2868 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2869 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2870 @example
2871 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2872 > adapter_khz 500
2873 @end example
2874 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2875 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2876 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2877 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2878 large set of samples.
2879 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2880 @example
2881 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2882 @end example
2883 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2884 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2885
2886 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2887 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2888 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2889 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2890 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2891 @end quotation
2892 @end deffn
2893
2894 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2895 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2896 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2900 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2901
2902 @example
2903 interface parport
2904 parport_port 0x278
2905 parport_cable wiggler
2906 @end example
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2910 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2911 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2912 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2913 @end deffn
2914 @end deffn
2915
2916 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2917 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2921 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2922 @end deffn
2923
2924 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2925 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2926
2927 @quotation Note
2928 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2929 which are not currently documented here.
2930 @end quotation
2931 @end deffn
2932
2933 @anchor{hla_interface}
2934 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2935 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2936 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2937 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2938
2939 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2940 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2941 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2942 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2943 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2944
2945 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2946 Currently Not Supported.
2947 @end deffn
2948
2949 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2950 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2951 @end deffn
2952
2953 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2954 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2955 @end deffn
2956
2957 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2958 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2962 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2963 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2964 @end deffn
2965 @end deffn
2966
2967 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2968 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2969 @end deffn
2970
2971 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2972 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2973 @end deffn
2974
2975 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2976 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2977 @end deffn
2978
2979 @quotation Note
2980 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2981 which are not currently documented here.
2982 @end quotation
2983
2984 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2985 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2986 No arguments: print status.
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2990 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2991 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2992
2993 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2994 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2995 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2996 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2997 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2998 configuration on exit.
2999
3000 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3001 pinout.
3002
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @section Transport Configuration
3006 @cindex Transport
3007 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3008 and the debug adapter you are using,
3009 several transports may be available to
3010 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3011 @deffn Command {transport list}
3012 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3013 version of OpenOCD.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3017 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3018
3019 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3020 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3021 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3022 adapter's driver).
3023
3024 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3025 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3026 supported by the debug adapter.
3027
3028 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3029 transport, if any.
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @subsection JTAG Transport
3033 @cindex JTAG
3034 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3035 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3036 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3037 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3038 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3039 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3040
3041 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3042 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3043 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3044 hla_jtag}.
3045
3046 @subsection SWD Transport
3047 @cindex SWD
3048 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3049 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3050 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3051 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3052 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3053 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3054 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3055
3056 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3057 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3058 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3059 hla_swd}.
3060
3061 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3062 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3063 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3064 expected to change.
3065 @end deffn
3066 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3067 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3068 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3069 No parameters: displays current settings.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @subsection SPI Transport
3073 @cindex SPI
3074 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3075 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3076 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3077 solution for flash programming.
3078
3079 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3080 @section JTAG Speed
3081 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3082 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3083 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3084 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3085 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3086 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3087 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3088 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3089 power management software that may be active.
3090
3091 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3092 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3093 target event handler.
3094 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3095 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3096 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3097 sets up those clocks).
3098 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3099 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3100 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3101 in the target config file.
3102 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3103 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3104 config file instead.
3105 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3106 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3107 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3108
3109 @example
3110 jtag_rclk 3000
3111 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3112 @end example
3113
3114 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3115 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3116 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3117 may not be the fastest solution.
3118
3119 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3120 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3121 which support adaptive clocking.
3122
3123 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3124 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3125 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3126 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3127 than the speed specified.
3128
3129 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3130 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3131 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3132 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3133
3134 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3135 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3136 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3137 JTAG clocking after setup.
3138 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3139 If the interface device can not
3140 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3144 @cindex adaptive clocking
3145 @cindex RTCK
3146 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3147 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3148 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3149 @example
3150 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3151 jtag_rclk 3000
3152 @end example
3153 @end defun
3154
3155 @node Reset Configuration
3156 @chapter Reset Configuration
3157 @cindex Reset Configuration
3158
3159 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3160 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3161 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3162 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3163 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3164 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3165 Please see the various board files for examples.
3166
3167 @quotation Note
3168 To maintainers and integrators:
3169 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3170 Normally the board configuration file
3171 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3172 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3173
3174 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3175 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3176 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3177 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3178 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3179 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3180 @end quotation
3181
3182 @section Types of Reset
3183
3184 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3185 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3186 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3187
3188 @itemize @bullet
3189 @item
3190 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3191 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3192 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3193 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3194 @item
3195 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3196 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3197 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3198 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3199 @item
3200 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3201 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3202 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3203 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3204 @item
3205 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3206 several other types of reset.
3207 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3208 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3209 There may be individual module resets.
3210 @end itemize
3211
3212 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3213 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3214 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3215 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3216 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3217 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3218 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3219 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3220 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3221
3222 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3223 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3224
3225 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3226 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3227 common issues are:
3228
3229 @itemize @bullet
3230
3231 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3232 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3233 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3234 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3235 when either of those signals is not connected.
3236 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3237 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3238 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3239 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3240
3241 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3242 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3243 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3244 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3245
3246 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3247 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3248 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3249 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3250 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3251 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3252 hardware debouncing.
3253 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3254 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3255
3256 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3257 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3258 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3259 to use push/pull output drivers.
3260 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3261 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3262 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3263 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3264
3265 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3266 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3267 issues (not limited to errata).
3268 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3269 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3270 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3271 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3272 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3273 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3274 @end itemize
3275
3276 There can also be other issues.
3277 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3278 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3279 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3280 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3281 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3282 Agreement (NDA).
3283
3284 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3285 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3286 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3287
3288 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3289 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3290
3291 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3292
3293 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3294 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3295 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3296 allowing it to be deasserted.
3297 @end deffn
3298
3299 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3300 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3301 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3302 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3303 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3304 @end deffn
3305
3306 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3307 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3308 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3309 allowing it to be deasserted.
3310 @end deffn
3311
3312 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3313 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3314 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3315 @end deffn
3316
3317 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3318 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3319 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3320 configuration scripts.
3321
3322 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3323 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3324 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3325 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3326 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3327 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3328 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3329 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3330
3331 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3332 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3333 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3334 -- may be specified at a time.
3335 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3336 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3337 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3338 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3339 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3340
3341 @itemize
3342 @item
3343 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3344 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3345 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3346 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3347 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3348
3349 @quotation Tip
3350 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3351 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3352 @end quotation
3353
3354 @item
3355 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3356 signal implementations.
3357 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3358 indicating everything behaves normally.
3359 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3360 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3361 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3362 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3363 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3364 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3365 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3366
3367 @item
3368 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3369 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3370 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3371 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3372 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3373 while SRST is asserted.
3374 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3375 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3376
3377 @item
3378 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3379 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3380 is required to use this option.
3381 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3382 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3383 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3384 be asserted before any target connection.
3385 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3386 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3387 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3388 @end itemize
3389
3390 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3391 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3392 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3393 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3394 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3395
3396 @itemize
3397 @item
3398 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3399 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3400 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3401 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3402
3403 @item
3404 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3405 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3406 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3407 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3408 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3409 @end itemize
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @section Custom Reset Handling
3413 @cindex events
3414
3415 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3416 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3417 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3418 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3419 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3420 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3421
3422 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3423 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3424 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3425 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3426 want to reset everything at once.
3427
3428 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3429 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3430 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3431 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3432 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3433 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3434 needs special attention.
3435
3436 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3437 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3438 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3439 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3440 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3441 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3442 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3443 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3444
3445 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3446 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3447 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3448 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3449 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3450
3451 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3452 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3453 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3454 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3455 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3456 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3457 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3458 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3459 or potentially some other value.
3460
3461 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3462 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3463 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3464 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3465 (or their associated targets)
3466 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3467
3468 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3469 they return.
3470 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3471 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3472 @end deffn
3473
3474 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3475 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3476 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3477 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3478 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3479 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3480 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3481 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3482 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3483 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3484 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3485 @end deffn
3486
3487 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3488 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3489 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3490 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3491 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3492 @end deffn
3493
3494
3495 @node TAP Declaration
3496 @chapter TAP Declaration
3497 @cindex TAP declaration
3498 @cindex TAP configuration
3499
3500 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3501 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3502
3503 @itemize @bullet
3504 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3505 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3506 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3507 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3508 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3509 start running that code.
3510 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3511 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3512 and missing connections.
3513 @end itemize
3514
3515 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3516 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3517 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3518 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3519 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3520
3521 @section Scan Chains
3522 @cindex scan chain
3523
3524 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3525 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3526 They also need to be added to
3527 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3528 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3529 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3530 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3531 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3532 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3533 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3534 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3535
3536 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3537 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3538 command, presented in the next chapter.
3539 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3540 debugging targets.)
3541 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3542
3543 @verbatim
3544 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3545 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3546 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3547 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3548 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3549 @end verbatim
3550
3551 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3552 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3553 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3554 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3555 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3556 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3557 until they are told to do so.
3558
3559 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3560 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3561 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3562 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3563
3564 @example
3565 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3566 @end example
3567
3568 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3569 by a given chip.
3570 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3571 and so forth.
3572 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3573 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3574 both inside a single chip and between them.
3575 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3576
3577 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3578 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3579 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3580 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3581 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3582 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3583 includes commands something like this:
3584
3585 @example
3586 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3587 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3588 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3589 @end example
3590
3591 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3592 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3593 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3594
3595 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3596 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3597 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3598 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3599 @example
3600 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3601 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3602 @}
3603 @end example
3604 @end deffn
3605
3606 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3607 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3608 and their status.
3609 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3610 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3611 but systems with a JTAG router can
3612 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3613 @end deffn
3614
3615 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3616 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3617
3618 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3619 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3620
3621 @section TAP Names
3622 @cindex dotted name
3623
3624 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3625 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3626 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3627 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3628 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3629 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3630 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3631 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3632
3633 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3634 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3635 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3636
3637 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3638
3639 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3640 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3641 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3642 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3643
3644 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3645 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3646 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3647 overridable.
3648
3649 @cindex TAP naming convention
3650 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3651 and should follow this convention:
3652
3653 @itemize @bullet
3654 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3655 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3656 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3657 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3658 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3659 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3660 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3661 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3662 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3663 with a single TAP;
3664 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3665 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3666 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3667 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3668 @end itemize
3669
3670 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3671
3672 @itemize @bullet
3673 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3674 @*The length in bits of the
3675 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3676 @end itemize
3677
3678 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3679
3680 @itemize @bullet
3681 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3682 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3683 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3684 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3685 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3686 (the TAP is linked in).
3687 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3688 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3689 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3690 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3691 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3692 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3693 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3694 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3695 values that were found but not included in the list.
3696
3697 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3698 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3699 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3700 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3701 hardware to find these values.
3702 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3703 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3704 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3705 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3706 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3707 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3708 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3709 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3710 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3711 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3712 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3713 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3714 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3715 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3716 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3717 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3718 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3719 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3720 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3721 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3722 @end itemize
3723 @end deffn
3724
3725 @section Other TAP commands
3726
3727 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3728 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3729 At this writing this TAP attribute
3730 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3731 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3732 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3733 See the next section for information about the available events.
3734
3735 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3736 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3737 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3738 @end deffn
3739
3740 @section TAP Events
3741 @cindex events
3742 @cindex TAP events
3743
3744 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3745 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3746 The other applies to debugger targets,
3747 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3748
3749 The TAP events currently defined are:
3750
3751 @itemize @bullet
3752 @item @b{post-reset}
3753 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3754 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3755 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3756 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3757 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3758
3759 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3760 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3761 of any particular target.
3762 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3763 @item @b{setup}
3764 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3765 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3766 @item @b{tap-disable}
3767 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3768 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3769 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3770 @item @b{tap-enable}
3771 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3772 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3773 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3774 @end itemize
3775
3776 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3777 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3778 contents to be accurate), you might:
3779
3780 @example
3781 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3782 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3783 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3784 @}
3785 @end example
3786
3787
3788 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3789 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3790 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3791 @cindex jrc
3792
3793 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3794 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3795 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3796 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3797 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3798
3799 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3800 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3801 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3802 be visible.
3803 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3804 ignores, such as:
3805
3806 @itemize
3807 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3808 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3809 TAPs receive new instructions.
3810 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3811 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3812 @end itemize
3813
3814 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3815 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3816 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3817 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3818
3819 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3820 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3821
3822 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3823 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3824 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3825 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3826 should define TAP event handlers using
3827 code that looks something like this:
3828
3829 @example
3830 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3831 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3832 @}
3833 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3834 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3835 @}
3836 @end example
3837
3838 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3839
3840 @example
3841 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3842 @end example
3843
3844 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3845 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3846 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3847 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3848
3849 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3850 If necessary, disables the tap
3851 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3852 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3853 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3854 and "0" if it is disabled.
3855 @end deffn
3856
3857 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3858 If necessary, enables the tap
3859 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3860 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3861 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3862 and "0" if it is disabled.
3863 @end deffn
3864
3865 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3866 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3867 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3868 and "0" if it is disabled.
3869
3870 @quotation Note
3871 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3872 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3873 @end quotation
3874 @end deffn
3875
3876 @anchor{autoprobing}
3877 @section Autoprobing
3878 @cindex autoprobe
3879 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3880
3881 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3882 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3883 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3884 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3885
3886 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3887 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3888 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3889 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3890 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3891 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3892 right when they come out of reset).
3893
3894 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3895
3896 @example
3897 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3898 reset_config trst_and_srst
3899 jtag_rclk 8
3900 @end example
3901
3902 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3903 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3904
3905 @enumerate
3906 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3907 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3908 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3909 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3910 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3911 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3912 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3913 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3914 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3915 that is discovered.
3916 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3917 register, it will report it.
3918 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3919 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3920 @end enumerate
3921
3922 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3923 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3924 that's a bit more complex:
3925
3926 @example
3927 clock speed 8 kHz
3928 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3929 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3930 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3931 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3932 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3933 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3934 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3935 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3936 @end example
3937
3938 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3939 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3940 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3941 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3942 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3943 and so forth.
3944
3945 @node CPU Configuration
3946 @chapter CPU Configuration
3947 @cindex GDB target
3948
3949 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3950 You can also access these targets without GDB
3951 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3952 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3953 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3954 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3955
3956 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3957 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3958
3959 @section Target List
3960 @cindex target, current
3961 @cindex target, list
3962
3963 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3964 where each member has a name.
3965 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3966 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3967 (plural!) command.
3968 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3969 look like with more than one:
3970 @verbatim
3971 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3972 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3973 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3974 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3975 @end verbatim
3976
3977 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3978 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3979 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3980 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3981 space seen by that current target.
3982 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3983 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3984 are examples; and there are many more.
3985
3986 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3987
3988 @deffn Command {target current}
3989 Returns the name of the current target.
3990 @end deffn
3991
3992 @deffn Command {target names}
3993 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3994 @example
3995 foreach t [target names] @{
3996 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3997 @}
3998 @end example
3999 @end deffn
4000
4001 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4002 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4003
4004 @deffn Command targets [name]
4005 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4006 command names are singular.}
4007
4008 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4009 targets in a user friendly form.
4010
4011 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4012 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4013 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4014 @end deffn
4015
4016 @section Target CPU Types
4017 @cindex target type
4018 @cindex CPU type
4019
4020 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4021 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4022 when calling @command{target create}.
4023 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4024 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4025 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4026 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4027 what core-specific commands may be available
4028 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4029 and more.
4030
4031 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4032 since there's a command to list them.
4033
4034 @anchor{targettypes}
4035 @deffn Command {target types}
4036 Lists all supported target types.
4037 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4038
4039 @itemize @bullet
4040 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4041 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4042 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4043 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4044 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4045 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4046 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4047 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4048 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4049 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4050 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4051 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4052 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4053 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4054 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4055 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4056 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4057 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4058 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4059 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4060 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4061 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4062 @itemize @minus
4063 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4064 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4065 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4066 @end itemize
4067 And two debug interfaces cores:
4068 @itemize @minus
4069 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4070 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4071 @end itemize
4072 @end itemize
4073 @end deffn
4074
4075 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4076 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4077 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4078 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4079 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4080 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4081 reflect design generations;
4082 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4083 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4084
4085 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4086 @section Target Configuration
4087
4088 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4089 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4090 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4091 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4092 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4093
4094 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4095 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4096 optional parts.
4097 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4098 command, created as part of target creation.
4099
4100 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4101 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4102 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4103 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4104 to be much more board-specific.
4105 The key steps you use might look something like this
4106
4107 @example
4108 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4109 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4110 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4111 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4112 @end example
4113
4114 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4115 on-chip SRAM.
4116 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4117 writes to target memory;
4118 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4119 GDB memory checksumming;
4120 and more.
4121
4122 @quotation Warning
4123 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4124 inaccessible when application code
4125 (such as an operating system)
4126 enables or disables the MMU.
4127 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4128 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4129 easy access to other addresses needed.
4130 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4131 @end quotation
4132
4133 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4134 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4135 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4136 controllers.
4137 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4138 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4139 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4140
4141 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4142 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4143 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4144 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4145 purposes including additional configuration.
4146
4147 @itemize @bullet
4148 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4149 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4150 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4151 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4152
4153 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4154 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4155 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4156 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4157 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4158 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4159 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4160
4161 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4162 @end itemize
4163 @end deffn
4164
4165 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4166 The options accepted by this command may also be
4167 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4168 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4169 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4170
4171 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4172 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4173 and changing its endianness.
4174
4175 @itemize @bullet
4176
4177 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4178 used to access this target.
4179
4180 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4181 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4182
4183 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4184 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4185 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4186 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4187 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4188 same event name assigns only one handler.
4189
4190 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4191 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4192 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4193 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4194 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4195 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4196 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4197
4198 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4199 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4200 or virtual address is being used.
4201
4202 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4203 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4204
4205 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4206 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4207 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4208 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4209 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4210
4211 @anchor{rtostype}
4212 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4213 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4214 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4215 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4216
4217 @end itemize
4218 @end deffn
4219
4220 @section Other $target_name Commands
4221 @cindex object command
4222
4223 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4224 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4225
4226 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4227 Once a button is created a button
4228 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4229 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4230 configure it like this:
4231
4232 @example
4233 # Create
4234 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4235 # Modify
4236 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4237 # Query
4238 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4239 # Report
4240 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4241 @end example
4242
4243 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4244 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4245
4246 @example
4247 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4248 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4249 @end example
4250
4251 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4252
4253 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4254 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4255 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4256 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4257 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4258 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4259 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4260 They are not otherwise documented here.
4261 @end deffn
4262
4263 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4264 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4265 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4266 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4267 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4268 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4269 the target side uses raw memory.
4270
4271 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4272 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4273 The script orientation comes from working with data
4274 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4275 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4276 and neither store nor return those values.
4277
4278 @itemize
4279 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4280 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4281 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4282 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4283 @end itemize
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4287 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4288 @command{$target_name configure}
4289 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4290 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4291 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4292 There are a few special cases:
4293
4294 @itemize @bullet
4295 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4296 event named @var{event_name}.
4297 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4298 two parameters.
4299 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4300 This is a special case because this is set using
4301 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4302 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4303 @end itemize
4304
4305 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4306 all the targets you might use something like this:
4307
4308 @example
4309 foreach name [target names] @{
4310 set y [$name cget -endian]
4311 set z [$name cget -type]
4312 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4313 $x $name $y $z]
4314 @}
4315 @end example
4316 @end deffn
4317
4318 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4319 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4320 Displays the current target state:
4321 @code{debug-running},
4322 @code{halted},
4323 @code{reset},
4324 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4325 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4326 @end deffn
4327
4328 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4329 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4330 currently associated with this target.
4331 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4332 @end deffn
4333
4334 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4335 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4336 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4337 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4341 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4342 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4343 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4344 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4345 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4346 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4347 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4348 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4349 @end deffn
4350
4351 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4352 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4353 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4354 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4355 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4356 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4357 @end deffn
4358
4359 @anchor{targetevents}
4360 @section Target Events
4361 @cindex target events
4362 @cindex events
4363 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4364 For example:
4365 @itemize @bullet
4366 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4367 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4368 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4369 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4370 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4371 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4372 to set up system clocks or
4373 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4374 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4375 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4376 @end itemize
4377
4378 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4379 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4380 @command{target create ... -event}.
4381
4382 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4383 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4384 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4385
4386 @example
4387 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4388 echo "Reset..."
4389 reset halt
4390 @}
4391 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4392 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4393 echo "Reset..."
4394 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4395 # we need a reset init.
4396 reset init
4397 @}
4398 @end example
4399
4400 The following target events are defined:
4401
4402 @itemize @bullet
4403 @item @b{debug-halted}
4404 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4405 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4406 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4407 @item @b{early-halted}
4408 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4409 @item @b{examine-start}
4410 @* Before target examine is called.
4411 @item @b{examine-end}
4412 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4413 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4414 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4415 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4416 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4417 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4418 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4419 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4420 @* When GDB disconnects
4421 @item @b{gdb-end}
4422 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4423 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4424 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4425 @code{reset init})
4426 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4427 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4428 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4429 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4430 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4431 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4432 @item @b{gdb-start}
4433 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4434 @item @b{halted}
4435 @* The target has halted
4436 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4437 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4438 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4439 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4440 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4441 @item @b{reset-assert}
4442 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4443 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4444 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4445 it instead of asserting SRST.
4446 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4447 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4448 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4449 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4450 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4451 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4452 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4453 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4454 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4455 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4456 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4457 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4458 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4459 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4460 released on the scan chain.
4461 @item @b{reset-end}
4462 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4463 @ignore
4464 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4465 @* Currently not used
4466 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4467 @* Currently not used
4468 @end ignore
4469 @item @b{reset-init}
4470 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4471 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4472
4473 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4474 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4475 multiplexing, and so on.
4476 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4477 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4478 @item @b{reset-start}
4479 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4480 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4481
4482 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4483 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4484 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4485 @ignore
4486 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4487 @* Currently not used
4488 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4489 @* Currently not used
4490 @end ignore
4491 @item @b{resume-start}
4492 @* Before any target is resumed
4493 @item @b{resume-end}
4494 @* After all targets have resumed
4495 @item @b{resumed}
4496 @* Target has resumed
4497 @item @b{trace-config}
4498 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4499 @end itemize
4500
4501 @node Flash Commands
4502 @chapter Flash Commands
4503
4504 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4505 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4506 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4507 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4508 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4509 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4510 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4511 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4512 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4513
4514 Flash Steps:
4515 @enumerate
4516 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4517 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4518 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4519 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4520 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4521 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4522 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4523 @item GDB Flashing
4524 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4525 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4526 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4527 @end enumerate
4528
4529 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4530 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4531 so that it can't boot.
4532 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4533 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4534
4535 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4536 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4537 @cindex flash configuration
4538
4539 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4540 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4541 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4542 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4543 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4544 see the driver-specific documentation.
4545
4546 @itemize @bullet
4547 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4548 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4549 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4550 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4551 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4552 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4553 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4554 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4555 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4556 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4557 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4558 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4559 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4560 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4561 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4562 commands to the flash controller.
4563 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4564 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4565 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4566 for more information.
4567 @end itemize
4568 @quotation Note
4569 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4570 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4571 @end quotation
4572 @end deffn
4573
4574 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4575 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4576 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4577 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4578 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4579 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4580 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @deffn Command {flash list}
4584 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4585 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4586 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4587 @end deffn
4588
4589 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4590 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4591 depends on the flash type.
4592 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4593 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4594 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4595 but most don't bother.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4599 @cindex flash erasing
4600 @cindex flash reading
4601 @cindex flash writing
4602 @cindex flash programming
4603 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4604
4605 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4606 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4607 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4608 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4609 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4610
4611 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4612 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4613 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4614 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4615 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4616
4617 @quotation Note
4618 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4619 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4620 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4621 back to a flash bank.
4622 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4623 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4624 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4625 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4626 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4627 @end quotation
4628
4629 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4630 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4631 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4632 disabled first.
4633 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4634 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4635 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4636
4637 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4638 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4639 up to and including @var{last}.
4640 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4641 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4642 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4643 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4644 @end deffn
4645
4646 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4647 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4648 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4649 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4650 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4651 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4652 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4653 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4654 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4655 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4656 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4657 before erase starts.
4658 @end deffn
4659
4660 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4661 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4662 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4663 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4664 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4665 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4666 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4667 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4668 before issuing this command.
4669 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4670 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4671 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4672 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4673 @end deffn
4674 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4675
4676 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4677 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4678 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4679 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4680 @end deffn
4681
4682 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4683 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4684 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4685 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4689 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4690 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4691 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4692 @end deffn
4693
4694 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4695 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4696 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4697 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4698 to the base address for each section in the image.
4699 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4700 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4701 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4702 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4703 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4704 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4705 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4706 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4707 each image section.
4708
4709 @quotation Warning
4710 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4711 data you want to preserve.
4712 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4713 sections might be erased with no notice.
4714 @itemize
4715 @item
4716 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4717 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4718 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4719 @item
4720 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4721 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4722 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4723 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4724 @end itemize
4725 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4726 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4727 @end quotation
4728
4729 @end deffn
4730
4731 @section Other Flash commands
4732 @cindex flash protection
4733
4734 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4735 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4736 and display that status.
4737 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4738 @end deffn
4739
4740 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4741 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4742 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4743 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4744 and possibly stale information.
4745 @end deffn
4746
4747 @anchor{flashprotect}
4748 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4749 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4750 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4751 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4752 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4753 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4754 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4755 @end deffn
4756
4757 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4758 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4759 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4760 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4761 @end deffn
4762
4763 @anchor{program}
4764 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4765 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4766 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4767 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4768 @end deffn
4769
4770 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4771 @section Flash Driver List
4772 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4773 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4774 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4775
4776 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4777 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4778 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4779
4780 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4781
4782 @itemize
4783 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4784 @end itemize
4785
4786 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4787 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4788 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4789 @example
4790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4791 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4792 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4793 @end example
4794 @end deffn
4795
4796 @subsection External Flash
4797
4798 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4799 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4800 @cindex CFI
4801 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4802 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4803 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4804 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4805 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4806 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4807 configure a bus and its timings), or
4808 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4809 on the flash chip.
4810 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4811 speed up operation.
4812
4813 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4814
4815 @itemize
4816 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4817 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4818 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4819 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4820 @end itemize
4821
4822 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4823 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4824
4825 @example
4826 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4827 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4828 @end example
4829
4830 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4831 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4832 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4833
4834 @example
4835 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4836 @end example
4837
4838 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4839 @end deffn
4840
4841 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4842 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4843 @cindex SPI
4844 @cindex jtagspi
4845 @cindex bscan_spi
4846 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4847 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4848 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4849 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4850 accessed through JTAG.
4851
4852 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4853 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4854 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4855 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4856 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4857 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4858
4859 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4860 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4861 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4862 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4863 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4864 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4865 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4866 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4867
4868 @itemize
4869 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4870 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4871 @var{USER1} instruction.
4872 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4873 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4874 @end itemize
4875
4876 @example
4877 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4878 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4879 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4881 @end example
4882 @end deffn
4883
4884 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4885 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4886 @cindex SPIFI
4887 @cindex lpcspifi
4888 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4889 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4890 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4891
4892 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4893 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4894 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4895 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4896 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4897
4898 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4899 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4900 are configured by the driver.
4901
4902 @example
4903 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4904 @end example
4905
4906 @end deffn
4907
4908 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4909 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4910 @cindex SMI
4911 @cindex stmsmi
4912 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4913 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4914 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4915 SPI flash devices.
4916 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4917 flash devices can be connected.
4918
4919 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4920 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4921 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4922 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4923 the flash content.
4924
4925 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4926 to identify the memory bank.
4927 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4928 flash size, are detected automatically.
4929
4930 @example
4931 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4932 @end example
4933
4934 @end deffn
4935
4936 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4937 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4938 Microcontroller platform.
4939
4940 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4941 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4942
4943 @example
4944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4945 @end example
4946
4947 @end deffn
4948
4949 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4950
4951 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4952 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4953 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4954 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4955 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4956 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4957
4958 @example
4959 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4960 @end example
4961 @end deffn
4962
4963 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4964 @cindex ambiqmicro
4965 @cindex apollo
4966 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4967 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4968 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4969 with the target using SWD.
4970
4971 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4972 the device class of the MCU.
4973 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4974 to set up the flash banks.
4975 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4976 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4977
4978 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4979 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4980 and the second bank starts after the first.
4981
4982 @example
4983 # Flash bank 0
4984 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4985 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4986 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4987 @end example
4988
4989 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
4990 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
4991 are available to the user.
4992
4993 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
4994
4995 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
4996 Erase entire bank.
4997 @end deffn
4998 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
4999 Erase device pages.
5000 @end deffn
5001 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5002 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5003 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
5004 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
5005 the flash.
5006 @end deffn
5007 @end deffn
5008
5009 @anchor{at91samd}
5010 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5011 @cindex at91samd
5012 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5013 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5014 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5015
5016 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5017 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5018 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5019 processor to be halted.
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5023 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5024 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5025 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5026 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5027 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5028
5029 @example
5030 at91samd set-security enable
5031 @end example
5032 @end deffn
5033
5034 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5035 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5036 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5037 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5038 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5039 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
5040 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5041 in order to disable this feature.
5042
5043 @example
5044 at91samd eeprom
5045 at91samd eeprom 1024
5046 @end example
5047 @end deffn
5048
5049 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5050 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5051 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5052 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5053 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5054 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5055
5056 @example
5057 at91samd bootloader
5058 at91samd bootloader 16384
5059 @end example
5060 @end deffn
5061
5062 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5063 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5064 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5065 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5066 @end deffn
5067
5068 @end deffn
5069
5070 @anchor{at91sam3}
5071 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5072 @cindex at91sam3
5073 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5074 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5075 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5076 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5077 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5078 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5079 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5080 chips are confirmed.}
5081
5082 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5083 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5084 the following fixed locations:
5085
5086 @example
5087 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5088 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5089 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5091 @end example
5092
5093 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5094 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5095 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5096
5097 @itemize
5098 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5099 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5100 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5101 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5102 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5103 @end itemize
5104
5105 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5106
5107 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5108 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5109 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5110 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5111 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5112 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5113 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5114
5115 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5116 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5117 @end deffn
5118
5119 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5120 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5121 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5122 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5123 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5124 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5125 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5126 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5130 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5131 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5132 @end deffn
5133 @end deffn
5134
5135 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5136 @cindex at91sam4
5137 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5138 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5139 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5140 @end deffn
5141
5142 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5143 @cindex at91sam4l
5144 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5145 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5146 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5147
5148 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5149 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5150 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5151 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5152 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5153 @end deffn
5154 @end deffn
5155
5156 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5157 @cindex atsamv
5158 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5159 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5160 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5161 @end deffn
5162
5163 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5164 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5165 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5166 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5167 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5168
5169 @example
5170 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5171 @end example
5172
5173 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5174 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5175
5176 @itemize
5177 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5178 @item @var{banks}
5179 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5180 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5181 @item @var{pages_size}
5182 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5183 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5184 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5185 @end itemize
5186
5187 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5188 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5189 will be autoconfigured.
5190 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5191
5192 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5193 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5194 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5195 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5196 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5197
5198 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5199 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5200 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5201 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5202 are not truly general purpose).
5203 @quotation Note
5204 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5205 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5206 @end quotation
5207 @end deffn
5208 @end deffn
5209
5210 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5211 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5212 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5213 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5214 @end deffn
5215
5216 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5217 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5218 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5219 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5220 autoconfigures itself.
5221 @example
5222 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5223 @end example
5224 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5225 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5226 this via the following command:
5227 @example
5228 efm32 debuglock num
5229 @end example
5230 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5231 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5232 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5233 supported.}
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5237 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5238 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5239 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5240 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5241 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5242 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5243
5244 @example
5245 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5246 @end example
5247 @end deffn
5248
5249 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5250 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5251 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5252 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5253 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5254 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5255 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5256 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5257 characters) ignored.
5258
5259 @example
5260 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5261 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5262 @end example
5263 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5264 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5265 @end deffn
5266
5267 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5268 @cindex kinetis
5269 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5270 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5271 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5272 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5273
5274 @example
5275 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5276 @end example
5277
5278 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5279 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5280 @end deffn
5281
5282 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5283 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5284 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5285 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5286 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5287 @end deffn
5288
5289 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5290 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5291 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5292 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5293 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5294
5295 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5296 Program Partition command.
5297
5298 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5299 Reset the device after partition setting.
5300
5301 Show partition size:
5302 @example
5303 kinetis nvm_partition info
5304 @end example
5305
5306 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5307 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5308 @example
5309 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5310 @end example
5311
5312 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5313 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5314 @example
5315 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5316 @end example
5317 @end deffn
5318
5319 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5320 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5321 Command disables watchdog timer.
5322 @end deffn
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5326 @cindex kinetis_ke
5327 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5328 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5329 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5330 autoconfigures itself.
5331
5332 @example
5333 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5334 @end example
5335
5336 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5337 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5338 @end deffn
5339
5340 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5341 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5342 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5343 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5344 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5345 @end deffn
5346
5347 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5348 Command disables watchdog timer.
5349 @end deffn
5350 @end deffn
5351
5352 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5353 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5354 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5355 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5356 microcontroller families from NXP.
5357
5358 @quotation Note
5359 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5360 driver:
5361 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5362 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5363 @end quotation
5364
5365 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5366 which must appear in the following order:
5367
5368 @itemize
5369 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5370 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5371 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5372 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5373 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5374 LPC43x[2357])
5375 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5376 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5377 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5378 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5379 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5380 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5381 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5382 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5383 at which the core is running
5384 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5385 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5386 @quotation Note
5387 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5388 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5389 However, if you do provide it,
5390 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5391 @end quotation
5392 @end itemize
5393
5394 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5395
5396 @example
5397 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5398 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5399 @end example
5400
5401 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5402 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5403 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5404 @end deffn
5405 @end deffn
5406
5407 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5408 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5409 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5410 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5411 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5412 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5413
5414 @example
5415 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5416 @end example
5417 @end deffn
5418
5419 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5420 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5421 from NXP.
5422
5423 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5424 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5425 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5426 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5427 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5428 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5429 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5430 you start the PLL.
5431
5432 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5433
5434 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5435 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5436 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5437
5438 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5439 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5440 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5441 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5442 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5443 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5444 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5445
5446 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5447 @example
5448 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5449 @end example
5450
5451 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5452 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5453 @code{flash banks} command.
5454
5455 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5456 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5457 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5458 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5459 a known signature.
5460 Example:
5461 @example
5462 lpc2900 signature 0
5463 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5464 @end example
5465 @end deffn
5466
5467 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5468 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5469 saves it to a file in binary format.
5470 Example:
5471 @example
5472 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5473 @end example
5474 @end deffn
5475
5476 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5477 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5478 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5479 command:
5480
5481 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5482 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5483 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5484 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5485
5486 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5487 Example:
5488 @example
5489 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5490 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5491 @end example
5492 @end deffn
5493
5494 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5495 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5496 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5497 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5498 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5499 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5500 912 bytes.
5501 @quotation Attention
5502 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5503 @end quotation
5504 Example:
5505 @example
5506 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5507 @end example
5508 @end deffn
5509
5510 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5511 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5512 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5513 after the next power cycle.
5514 @quotation Attention
5515 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5516 @end quotation
5517 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5518 Example:
5519 @example
5520 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5521 flash info 0
5522 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5523 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5524 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5525 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5526 @end example
5527 @end deffn
5528
5529 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5530 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5531 effective after the next power cycle.
5532 @quotation Attention
5533 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5534 @end quotation
5535 Examples:
5536 @example
5537 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5538 @end example
5539 @end deffn
5540 @end deffn
5541
5542 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5543 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5544 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5545 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5546
5547 @example
5548 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5549 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5550 @end example
5551
5552 @itemize @bullet
5553 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5554 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5555 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5556 @end itemize
5557
5558 Example usage:
5559 @example
5560 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5561 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5562 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5563 @} else @{
5564 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5565 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5566 @}
5567 @end example
5568 @end deffn
5569
5570 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5571 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5572 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5573 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5574 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5575 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5576 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5577 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5578 also have division into regions: main and info.
5579 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5580 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5581
5582 @example
5583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5584 @end example
5585
5586 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5587
5588 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5589 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5590 @end deffn
5591
5592 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5593 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5597 Erase all userflash including info region.
5598 @end deffn
5599
5600 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5601 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5602 @end deffn
5603
5604 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5605 Check sectors protect.
5606 @end deffn
5607
5608 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5609 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5610 @end deffn
5611
5612 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5613 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5614 @end deffn
5615
5616 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5617 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5621 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5622 @end deffn
5623
5624 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5625 Show information about flash driver.
5626 @end deffn
5627
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5631 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5632 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5633
5634 @example
5635 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5636 @end example
5637
5638 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5639
5640 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5641 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5642 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5643 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5644 code.
5645 @end deffn
5646
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5650 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5651 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5652
5653 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5654 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5655 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5656 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5657
5658 @example
5659 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5660 @end example
5661 @end deffn
5662
5663 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5664 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5665 and integrate flash memory.
5666
5667 @example
5668 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5669 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5670 @end example
5671
5672 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5673 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5674 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5675 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5676 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5677 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5678 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5679 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5680 @end deffn
5681 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5682 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5683 This will remove any Code Protection.
5684 @end deffn
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5688 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5689 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5690 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5691 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5692
5693 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5694 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5695
5696 @example
5697 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5698 @end example
5699
5700 psoc4-specific commands
5701 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5702 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5703
5704 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5705 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5706
5707 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5708 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5709 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5710
5711 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5715 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5716
5717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5718 @end deffn
5719 @end deffn
5720
5721 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5722 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5723 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5724 and SWD interface.
5725 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5726 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5727
5728 @example
5729 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5730 @end example
5731
5732 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5733
5734 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5735 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5736 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5740 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5741 @end deffn
5742 @end deffn
5743
5744 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5745 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5746 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5747 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5748 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5749 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5750 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5751 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5752
5753 @example
5754 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5755 @end example
5756
5757 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5758 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5759 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5760 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5761 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5762 disabled.
5763
5764 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5765 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5766 @quotation Warning
5767 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5768 applied to all of them.
5769 @end quotation
5770 @end deffn
5771 @end deffn
5772
5773 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5774 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5775 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5776 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5777 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5778
5779 @example
5780 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5781 @end example
5782
5783 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5784 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5785 the flash driver.
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5789 @end example
5790
5791 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5792 as per the following example.
5793 @example
5794 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5795 @end example
5796
5797 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5798 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5799 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5800 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5801 are defined:
5802
5803 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5804 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5805 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5809 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5810 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5811 @end deffn
5812
5813 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5814 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5815 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5816 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5820 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5821 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5822 @end deffn
5823 @end deffn
5824
5825 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5826 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5827 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5828 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5829 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5830
5831 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5832 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5833 the flash driver.
5834
5835 @example
5836 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5837 @end example
5838
5839 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5840
5841 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5842 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5843 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5844 @end deffn
5845
5846 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5847 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5848 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5849 @end deffn
5850 @end deffn
5851
5852 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5853 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5854 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5855 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5856 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5857
5858 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5859 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5860 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5861 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5862 second bank.
5863
5864 @example
5865 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5866 @end example
5867
5868 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5869
5870 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5871 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5872 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5873 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5874 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5875 @end deffn
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5879 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5880 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5881 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5882 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5883
5884 @example
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5886 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5887 @end example
5888
5889 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5890 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5891 for the specified flash bank.
5892 @end deffn
5893 @end deffn
5894
5895 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5896 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5897 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5898 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5899 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5900
5901 @example
5902 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5903 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5904 @end example
5905
5906 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5907 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5908 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5909
5910 @itemize @bullet
5911 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5912 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5913 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5914 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5915 @end itemize
5916 @end deffn
5917
5918 @end deffn
5919
5920 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5921 @cindex str9xpec
5922
5923 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5924 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5925 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5926 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5927
5928 Here is some background info to help
5929 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5930 the str9:
5931 @enumerate
5932 @item
5933 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5934 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5935 @item
5936 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5937 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5938 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5939 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5940 @end enumerate
5941
5942 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5943 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5944 configured for flash bank 0.
5945 @example
5946 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5947 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5948 jtag_reset 0 1
5949 # turn off target polling
5950 poll off
5951 # disable str9 core
5952 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5953 # read option bytes
5954 str9xpec options_read 0
5955 # re-enable str9 core
5956 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5957 poll on
5958 reset halt
5959 @end example
5960 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5961 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5962 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5963 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5964
5965 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5966
5967 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5968 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5972 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5973 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5974 @end deffn
5975
5976 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5977 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5978 erase the device.
5979 @end deffn
5980
5981 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5982 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5983 @end deffn
5984
5985 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5986 Configure str9 boot bank.
5987 @end deffn
5988
5989 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5990 Configure str9 lvd source.
5991 @end deffn
5992
5993 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5994 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5995 @end deffn
5996
5997 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5998 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6002 Read str9 option bytes.
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6006 Write str9 option bytes.
6007 @end deffn
6008
6009 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6010 unlock str9 device.
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6016 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6017 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6018 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6019
6020 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6021
6022 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6023 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6024 @end deffn
6025
6026 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6027 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6031 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6032 the flash clock.
6033 @end deffn
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6037 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6038 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6042 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6043 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6044
6045 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6046
6047 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6048 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6049 @end deffn
6050
6051 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6052 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6053 @end deffn
6054
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @section NAND Flash Commands
6058 @cindex NAND
6059
6060 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6061 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6062 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6063
6064 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6065 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6066 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6067 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6068 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6069 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6070
6071 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6072 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6073 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6074 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6075 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6076 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6077 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6078 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6079 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6080 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6081
6082 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6083 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6084 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6085 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6086 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6087 every 512 bytes of data.
6088
6089 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6090 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6091 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6092 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6093 ECC mode is used.
6094
6095 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6096 @enumerate
6097 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6098 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6099 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6100 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6101 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6102 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6103 to access that device.
6104 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6105 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6106 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6107 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6108 de-brick a board.
6109 @end enumerate
6110
6111 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6112 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6113 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6114 are only 32 bits wide.
6115 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6116 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6117 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6118 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6119
6120 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6121 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6122 @cindex NAND configuration
6123
6124 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6125 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6126 OpenOCD has initialized.
6127
6128 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6129 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6130 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6131 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6132 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6133 they were a single (larger) device.
6134 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6135 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6136
6137 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6138 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6139 configuration files, not interactively.
6140
6141 @itemize @bullet
6142 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6143 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6144 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6145 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6146 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6147 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6148 commands to the NAND controller.
6149 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6150 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6151 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6152 for more information.
6153 @end itemize
6154 @end deffn
6155
6156 @deffn Command {nand list}
6157 Prints a summary of each device declared
6158 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6159 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6160 @example
6161 > nand list
6162 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6163 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6164 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6165 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6166 >
6167 @end example
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6171 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6172 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6173 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6174 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6175 it with most other NAND commands.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6179
6180 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6181 @cindex NAND reading
6182 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6183 starting at the specified offset.
6184 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6185
6186 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6187 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6188
6189 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6190 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6191 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6192
6193 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6194 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6195 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6196 method which handled that error correction.
6197
6198 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6199 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6200 @itemize @bullet
6201 @item no oob_* parameter
6202 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6203 @item @code{oob_raw}
6204 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6205 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6206 spare areas associated with each data page.
6207 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6208 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6209 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6210 @item @code{oob_only}
6211 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6212 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6213 spare areas associated with each data page.
6214 @end itemize
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6218 @cindex NAND erasing
6219 @cindex NAND programming
6220 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6221 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6222 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6223 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6224 If those parameters are not specified,
6225 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6226 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6227
6228 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6229 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6230 block marker.
6231 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6232 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6233 @end deffn
6234
6235 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6236 @cindex NAND writing
6237 @cindex NAND programming
6238 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6239 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6240 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6241 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6242
6243 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6244 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6245
6246 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6247 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6248 past the end of the device.
6249 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6250 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6251 if that's being written.)
6252
6253 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6254 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6255 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6256
6257 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6258 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6259 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6260 @itemize @bullet
6261 @item no oob_* parameter
6262 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6263 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6264 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6265 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6266 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6267 @item @code{oob_only}
6268 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6269 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6270 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6271 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6272 @item @code{oob_raw}
6273 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6274 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6275 un-altered OOB.
6276 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6277 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6278 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6279 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6280 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6281 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6282 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6283 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6284 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6285 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6286 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6287 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6288 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6289 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6290 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6291 @end itemize
6292 @end deffn
6293
6294 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6295 @cindex NAND verification
6296 @cindex NAND programming
6297 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6298 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6299 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6300
6301 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6302 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6303
6304 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6305 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6306 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6307 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6308 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6309
6310 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6311 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6312 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6313
6314 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6315 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6316 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6317 be removed in a future release.
6318 @end deffn
6319
6320 @subsection Other NAND commands
6321 @cindex NAND other commands
6322
6323 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6324 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6325 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6326 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6327 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6328 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6329 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6330 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6331
6332 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6333 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6334 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6338 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6339 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6340 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6341 status for each block.
6342 @end deffn
6343
6344 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6345 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6346 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6347
6348 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6349 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6350 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6351 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6352 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6353
6354 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6355 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6356 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6357 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6358 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6359 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6360 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6364 @subsection NAND Driver List
6365 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6366 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6367 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6368
6369 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6370 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6371 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6372 address of the ECC controller.
6373 @example
6374 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6375 @end example
6376 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6377 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6378 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6379 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6380 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6381 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6382 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6383 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6384 @end deffn
6385 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6386 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6387 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6388 @end deffn
6389
6390 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6391 properly configured for input or output.
6392 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6393 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6394 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6395 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6396 @end deffn
6397 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6398 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6399 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6400 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6401 @end deffn
6402 @end deffn
6403
6404 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6405 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6406 chips from Texas Instruments.
6407 It takes three extra parameters:
6408 address of the NAND chip;
6409 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6410 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6411 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6412 @example
6413 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6414 @end example
6415 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6416 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6417 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6418 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6419 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6420 @end deffn
6421
6422 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6423 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6424 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6425 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6426 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6427 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6428 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6432 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6433 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6434 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6435 @end deffn
6436 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6437
6438 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6439 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6440 should work for this chip aswell.
6441 @end deffn
6442
6443 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6444 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6445 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6446 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6447 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6448 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6449 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6450 @example
6451 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6452 @end example
6453 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6454 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6455 without parameter query status.
6456 @end deffn
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6460 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6461 parameter: the address of the controller.
6462 @example
6463 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6464 @end example
6465 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6466 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6467 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6468 change any behavior.
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6472 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6473 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6474 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6475 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6476 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6477 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6478 specialized commands.
6479 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6480 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6481 change any behavior.
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @section mFlash
6485
6486 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6487 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6488
6489 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6490 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6491 address @var{base}.
6492 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6493 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6494
6495 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6496
6497 @example
6498 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6499 @end example
6500
6501 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6502
6503 @example
6504 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6505 @end example
6506 @end deffn
6507
6508 @subsection mFlash commands
6509 @cindex mFlash commands
6510
6511 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6512 Configure mflash PLL.
6513 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6514 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6515 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6516 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6517 @end deffn
6518
6519 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6520 Configure bootable option.
6521 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6522 (4kB) for boot.
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6526 Configure storage information.
6527 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6528 written.
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6532 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6533 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6534 @end deffn
6535
6536 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6537 Probe mflash.
6538 @end deffn
6539
6540 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6541 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6542 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6543 @end deffn
6544
6545 @node Flash Programming
6546 @chapter Flash Programming
6547
6548 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6549 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6550 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6551
6552 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6553 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6554
6555 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6556 @enumerate
6557 @item 'init' is executed.
6558 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6559 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6560 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6561 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6562 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6563 @end enumerate
6564
6565 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6566
6567 @example
6568 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6569 # are optional parameters
6570 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6571 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6572
6573 # binary files need the flash address passing
6574 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6575 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6576 @end example
6577
6578 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6579 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6580 @cindex PLD
6581 @cindex FPGA
6582
6583 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6584 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6585 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6586 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6587 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6588 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6589 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6590
6591 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6592
6593 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6594 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6595 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6596
6597 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6598 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6599
6600 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6601 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6602 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6603 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6604 behavior.
6605 @end deffn
6606
6607 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6608 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6609 @end deffn
6610
6611 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6612 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6613 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6614 @end deffn
6615
6616 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6617
6618 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6619 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6620 that particular type of PLD.
6621
6622 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6623 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6624 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6625
6626 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6627 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6628 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6629
6630 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6631 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6632 for FPGA @var{num}.
6633 @end deffn
6634 @end deffn
6635
6636 @node General Commands
6637 @chapter General Commands
6638 @cindex commands
6639
6640 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6641 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6642 commands are documented elsewhere.
6643
6644 Intent:
6645 @itemize @bullet
6646 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6647 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6648 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6649 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6650
6651 @item @b{From the human}
6652 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6653 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6654
6655 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6656 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6657 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6658
6659 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6660 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6661 port is 5555.
6662 @end itemize
6663
6664
6665 @section Daemon Commands
6666
6667 @deffn {Command} exit
6668 Exits the current telnet session.
6669 @end deffn
6670
6671 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6672 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6673 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6674 Not every command provides helptext.
6675
6676 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6677 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6678 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6679 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6683 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6684 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6685 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6686 Useful in connection with script files
6687 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6691 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6692 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6693 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6694 @end deffn
6695
6696 @anchor{debuglevel}
6697 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6698 @cindex message level
6699 Display debug level.
6700 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6701 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6702 Level 0 is error messages only;
6703 level 1 adds warnings;
6704 level 2 adds informational messages;
6705 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6706 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6707 the command line along with the location of that log
6708 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6709 @xref{Running}.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6713 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6714 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6715 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6716 @example
6717 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6718 @end example
6719 @end deffn
6720
6721 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6722 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6723 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6724 @end deffn
6725
6726 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6727 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6731 @section Target State handling
6732 @cindex reset
6733 @cindex halt
6734 @cindex target initialization
6735
6736 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6737 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6738 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6739 a current target which is used to perform the
6740 various operations. The current target may be changed
6741 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6742 target which should become current.
6743
6744 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6745 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6746 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6747 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6748 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6749
6750 @emph{With no arguments}:
6751 list all available registers for the current target,
6752 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6753 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6754 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6755 are flagged as such.
6756
6757 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6758 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6759 bypassing any internal cache.
6760
6761 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6762 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6763 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6764 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6765 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6766 relevant module will flush such values.
6767
6768 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6769 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6770
6771 @example
6772 > reg
6773 ===== ARM registers
6774 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6775 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6776 (2) r2 (/32)
6777 ...
6778 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6779 >
6780 @end example
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6784 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6785 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6786 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6787 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6788 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6789 (and enter debug mode).
6790 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6791
6792 @quotation Warning
6793 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6794 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6795 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6796 power mode by gating the core clock;
6797 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6798
6799 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6800 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6801 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6802 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6803 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6804 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6805
6806 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6807 work with a JTAG debugger.
6808 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6809 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6810 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6811 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6812 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6813 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6814 @end quotation
6815
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @deffn Command resume [address]
6819 Resume the target at its current code position,
6820 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6821 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6822 @end deffn
6823
6824 @deffn Command step [address]
6825 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6826 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @anchor{resetcommand}
6830 @deffn Command reset
6831 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6832 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6833 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6834 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6835 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6836 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6837
6838 The optional parameter specifies what should
6839 happen after the reset.
6840 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6841 The other options will not work on all systems.
6842 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6843
6844 @itemize @minus
6845 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6846 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6847 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6848 @end itemize
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6852 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6853 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6854 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6855 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6856 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6857 state.
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @section I/O Utilities
6861
6862 These commands are available when
6863 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6864 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6865 notably the ZY1000.
6866 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6867
6868 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6869
6870 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6871 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6872 the text file @file{filename}.
6873 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6874 The last string is followed by a newline.
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @deffn Command cat filename
6878 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6882 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6883 into @file{dest_filename}.
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn Command ip
6887 @emph{No description provided.}
6888 @end deffn
6889
6890 @deffn Command ls
6891 @emph{No description provided.}
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn Command mac
6895 @emph{No description provided.}
6896 @end deffn
6897
6898 @deffn Command meminfo
6899 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6900 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command peek
6904 @emph{No description provided.}
6905 @end deffn
6906
6907 @deffn Command poke
6908 @emph{No description provided.}
6909 @end deffn
6910
6911 @deffn Command rm filename
6912 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6913 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn Command trunc filename
6917 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6918 @end deffn
6919
6920 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6921 @section Memory access commands
6922 @cindex memory access
6923
6924 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6925 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6926 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6927 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6928
6929 @enumerate
6930 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6931 to change the current target.
6932 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6933 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6934 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6935 @end enumerate
6936
6937 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6938 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6939 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6940 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6941 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6942 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6943 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6944 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6945 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6946 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6947 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6948 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6949 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6953 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6954 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6955 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6956 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6957 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6958 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6959 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6960 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6961 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6962 @end deffn
6963
6964 @anchor{imageaccess}
6965 @section Image loading commands
6966 @cindex image loading
6967 @cindex image dumping
6968
6969 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6970 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6971 binary file named @var{filename}.
6972 @end deffn
6973
6974 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6975 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6976 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6980 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6981 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6982 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6983 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6984 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6985 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6986 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6987 separately.
6988 @end deffn
6989
6990 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6991 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6992 The file format may optionally be specified
6993 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6994 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6995 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6996 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6997 @example
6998 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6999 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7000 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7001 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7002 $address $length
7003 @}
7004 @end example
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7008 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7009 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7010 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7011 The file format may optionally be specified
7012 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7016 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7017 The file format may optionally be specified
7018 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7019 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7020 @end deffn
7021
7022
7023 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7024 @cindex breakpoint
7025 @cindex watchpoint
7026
7027 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7028 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7029 watchpoints.
7030 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7031
7032 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7033 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7034 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7035 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7036 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7037 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7038
7039 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7040 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7044 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7048 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7049 @end deffn
7050
7051 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7052 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7053 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7054 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7055 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7056 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7057 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7058 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7059 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7060 @end deffn
7061
7062 @section Misc Commands
7063
7064 @cindex profiling
7065 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7066 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7067 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7068 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7069 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7070 limit the address range.
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn Command {version}
7074 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7078 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7079 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7083 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7084 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7085 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7086
7087 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7088 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7089 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7090 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7091
7092 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7093 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7094 @cindex tracing
7095 @cindex ETM
7096 @cindex ETB
7097
7098 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7099 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7100 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7101
7102 @itemize
7103 @item
7104 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7105 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7106 supports such an interface.
7107 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7108 and trace port support.)
7109 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7110 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7111 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7112 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7113 in the board-specific configuration file.
7114 @item
7115 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7116 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7117 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7118 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7119 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7120 @end itemize
7121
7122 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7123
7124 @quotation Issues
7125 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7126 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7127
7128 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7129 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7130 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7131 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7132 dummy trace port driver}.
7133
7134 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7135 as well as tracing only during specific states
7136 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7137
7138 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7139 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7140 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7141 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7142 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7143
7144 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7145 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7146 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7147 this original style of JTAG access.
7148 @end quotation
7149
7150 @subsection ETM Configuration
7151 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7152
7153 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7154 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7155 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7156
7157 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7158 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7159 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7160 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7161 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7162 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7163 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7164 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7165 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7166
7167 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7168 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7169 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7170
7171 @quotation Warning
7172 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7173 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7174 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7175 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7176 @end quotation
7177
7178 @quotation Note
7179 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7180 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7181 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7182 what CPU activities are traced.
7183 @end quotation
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn Command {etm info}
7187 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7188 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7189 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7190 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn Command {etm status}
7194 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7195 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7196 Did trace data overflow?
7197 Was it triggered?
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7201 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7202 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7203 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7204 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7205
7206 @itemize
7207 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7208 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7209 The value is one of
7210 @option{none} (save nothing),
7211 @option{data} (save data),
7212 @option{address} (save addresses),
7213 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7214 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7215 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7216 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7217 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7218 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7219 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7220 trace stream without an image of the code.
7221 @end itemize
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7225 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7226 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7227 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7228 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7229
7230 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7231 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7232 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7233 @end deffn
7234
7235 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7236
7237 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7238 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7239 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7240
7241 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7242 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7243 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7244 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7245 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7246 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7247 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7248
7249 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7250
7251 @itemize
7252 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7253 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7254 for instruction access within that function's body.
7255 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7256 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7257 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7258 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7259 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7260 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7261 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7262 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7263 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7264 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7265 @item @emph{... more}
7266 @end itemize
7267
7268 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7269 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7270
7271 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7272 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7273 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7277 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7281 Opens an image file.
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7285 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn Command {etm start}
7289 Starts trace data collection.
7290 @end deffn
7291
7292 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7293 Stops trace data collection.
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7297 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7298
7299 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7300
7301 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7302 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7303 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7304 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7305 any trace data collection.}
7306 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7307 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7308 @end deffn
7309 @end deffn
7310
7311 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7312 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7313 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7314 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7315 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7316 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7317 @end deffn
7318 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7319 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7320 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7321 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7322 trace trigger becomes active.
7323
7324 @itemize
7325 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7326 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7327 afterwards.
7328 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7329 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7330 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7331 what caused that event to happen.
7332 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7333 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7334 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7335 how the event caused trouble.
7336 @end itemize
7337 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7338 @end deffn
7339
7340 @end deffn
7341
7342 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7343 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7344 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7345 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7346 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7347
7348 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7349 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7350
7351 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7352 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7353 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7354 @end deffn
7355
7356 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7357 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7361 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7362 @end deffn
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365
7366 @section Generic ARM
7367 @cindex ARM
7368
7369 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7370 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7371 commands that may be available.
7372
7373 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7374 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7375 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7376 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7377 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7378 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7379 @end deffn
7380
7381 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7382 @cindex disassemble
7383 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7384 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7385 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7386 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7387 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7388 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7389 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7390
7391 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7392 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7393 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7394 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7395 with a handful of exceptions.
7396 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7400 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7401 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7402 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7403 and using the MCR instruction.
7404 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7405 an ARM register.)
7406 @end deffn
7407
7408 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7409 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7410 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7411 and the MRC instruction.
7412 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7413 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7414 an ARM register.)
7415 @end deffn
7416
7417 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7418 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7419 core mode if necessary.
7420 @end deffn
7421
7422 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7423 @cindex ARM semihosting
7424 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7425
7426 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7427 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7428 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7429 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7430 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7431 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7432 @end deffn
7433
7434 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7435 @cindex ARMv4
7436 @cindex ARMv5
7437
7438 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7439 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7440 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7441 variant.
7442
7443 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7444 @cindex ARM7
7445 @cindex ARM9
7446
7447 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7448 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7449 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7450 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7451
7452 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7453 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7454 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7455 instead of breakpoints.
7456 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7457
7458 This should be
7459 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7460 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7461 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7465 @cindex DCC
7466 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7467 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7468 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7469
7470 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7471 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7472 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7476 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7477 that don't check completion of the operation.
7478 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7479
7480 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7481 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7482 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7486 @cindex ARM720T
7487
7488 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7489 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7490 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7491 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7492
7493 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7494 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7495 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7496
7497 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7498 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7499 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7500 @end deffn
7501
7502 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7503 @cindex ARM9
7504
7505 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7506 integer processors.
7507 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7508
7509 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7510 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7511 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7512 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7513
7514 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7515 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7516 @cindex vector_catch
7517 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7518 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7519 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7520 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7521 to those hardware vectors.
7522
7523 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7524 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7525 vector catch hardware to intercept
7526 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7527 @option{none} of them,
7528 or a list with one or more of the following:
7529 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7530 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7531 @end deffn
7532
7533 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7534 @cindex ARM920T
7535
7536 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7537 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7538 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7539 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7540 and ARM9 commands.
7541
7542 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7543 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7544 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7548 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7549 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7550 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7551 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7552 (Not all registers can be written.)
7553 @end deffn
7554
7555 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7556 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7557 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7558
7559 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7560 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7561 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7562 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7563 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7564 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7565 @end deffn
7566
7567 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7568 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7572 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7573 @end deffn
7574
7575 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7576 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7577
7578 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7579 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7580 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7581 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7582 and ARM9 commands.
7583
7584 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7585 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7586
7587 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7588 Print information about the caches found.
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7592 @cindex ARM966E
7593
7594 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7595 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7596 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7597 and ARM9 commands.
7598
7599 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7600 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7601 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7602 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7603 ARM966E-S TRM.
7604 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7605 as required for BIST support.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @subsection XScale specific commands
7609 @cindex XScale
7610
7611 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7612
7613 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7614 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7615 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7616 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7617 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7618 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7619 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7620
7621 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7622 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7623 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7624 the mini-IC.
7625
7626 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7627 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7628 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7629 code layout in memory:
7630 @example
7631 _vectors:
7632 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7633 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7634 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7635 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7636 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7637 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7638 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7639 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7640 .org 0x100
7641 .long real_reset_vector
7642 .long real_ui_handler
7643 .long real_swi_handler
7644 .long real_pf_abort
7645 .long real_data_abort
7646 .long 0 /* unused */
7647 .long real_irq_handler
7648 .long real_fiq_handler
7649 @end example
7650
7651 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7652 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7653 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7654 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7655 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7656 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7657 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7658 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7659 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7660 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7661 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7662 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7663 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7664 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7665 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7666 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7667 software.
7668
7669 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7670 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7671 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7672 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7673
7674 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7675 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7676 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7677 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7678 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7679 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7680 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7681 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7682 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7683
7684 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7685 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7686
7687 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7688 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7689 @end deffn
7690
7691 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7692 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7693 @end deffn
7694
7695 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7696 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7697 @end deffn
7698
7699 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7700 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7701 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7705 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7706 @end deffn
7707
7708 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7709 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7710 @end deffn
7711
7712 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7713 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7714 @end deffn
7715
7716 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7717 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7721 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7722 @end deffn
7723
7724 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7725 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7726 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7727 and modifying how it is emptied.
7728 @end deffn
7729
7730 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7731 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7732 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7733 The image @var{type} may be one of
7734 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7735 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7736 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7737 @end deffn
7738
7739 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7740 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7741 @cindex vector_catch
7742 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7743 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7744
7745 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7746 @example
7747 0x01 Trap Reset
7748 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7749 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7750 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7751 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7752 0x20 reserved
7753 0x40 Trap IRQ
7754 0x80 Trap FIQ
7755 @end example
7756 @end deffn
7757
7758 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7759 @cindex vector_table
7760
7761 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7762 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7763 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7764 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7765 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7766
7767 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7768
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7772 @cindex ARMv6
7773
7774 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7775 @cindex ARM11
7776
7777 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7778 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7779 which is enabled by default.
7780 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7781 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7782 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7783 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7784 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7785 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7786 @end deffn
7787
7788 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7789 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7790 which is enabled by default.
7791 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7792 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7793 @end deffn
7794
7795 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7796 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7797 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7798 they are disabled by default.
7799 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7800 @end deffn
7801
7802 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7803 @cindex vector_catch
7804 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7805 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7806 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7807
7808 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7809 for certain hardware events.
7810 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7811 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7812 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7816 @cindex ARMv7
7817
7818 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7819 @cindex Debug Access Port
7820 @cindex DAP
7821 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7822 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7823 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7824
7825 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7826 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7827 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7828 @end deffn
7829
7830 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7831 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7832 @end deffn
7833
7834 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7835 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7836 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7840 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7841 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7842 @end deffn
7843
7844 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7845 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7846 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7847 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7851 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7852 Defaulting to 0.
7853 @end deffn
7854
7855 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7856 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7857 Disabled by default
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860
7861 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7862 @cindex Cortex-A
7863
7864 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7865 display information about target caches
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7869 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7870 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7871 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7872 Defaults to 'off'.
7873 @end deffn
7874
7875 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7876 Initialize core debug
7877 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7881 Disable SMP mode
7882 @end deffn
7883
7884 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7885 Enable SMP mode
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7889 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7893 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7897 configure l2x cache
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900
7901 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7902 @cindex Cortex-R
7903
7904 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7905 Initialize core debug
7906 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7907 @end deffn
7908
7909 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7910 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7911 @end deffn
7912
7913
7914 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7915 @cindex tracing
7916 @cindex SWO
7917 @cindex SWV
7918 @cindex TPIU
7919 @cindex ITM
7920 @cindex ETM
7921
7922 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7923 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7924 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7925
7926 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7927 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7928 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7929 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7930
7931 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7932 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7933 debugger adapter features.
7934
7935 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7936 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7937
7938 Command options:
7939 @itemize @minus
7940 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7941 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7942 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7943 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7944 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7945 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7946 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7947 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7948 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7949 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7950 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7951 coding;
7952 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7953 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7954 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7955 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7956 data is to be output via SWO;
7957 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7958 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7959 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7960 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7961 rate automatically.
7962 @end itemize
7963
7964 Example usage:
7965 @enumerate
7966 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7967 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7968 enough to:
7969 @example
7970 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7971 ...
7972 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7973 ...
7974 @end example
7975 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7976 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7977 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7978 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7979 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7980 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7981 @example
7982 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7983 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7984 @end example
7985 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7986 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7987 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7988 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7989 @example
7990 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7991 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7992 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7993 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7994 @end example
7995 @end enumerate
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7999 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8000 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8001 @end deffn
8002
8003 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8004 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8005 @end deffn
8006
8007 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8008 @cindex Cortex-M
8009
8010 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8011 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8012
8013 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8014 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8015 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8016 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8017 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8018 the step command leaves with the core running.
8019
8020 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8021 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8022 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8023
8024 Default is @option{auto}.
8025 @end deffn
8026
8027 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8028 @cindex vector_catch
8029 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8030 for certain hardware events.
8031
8032 Parameters request interception of
8033 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8034 @option{none} of them,
8035 or one or more of the following:
8036 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8037 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8038 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8039 @option{irq_err},
8040 @option{state_err},
8041 @option{chk_err}, or
8042 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8043 @option{reset}.
8044 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8045 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8046 are mapped to HardFault.
8047 UsageFault checks for
8048 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8049 must also be explicitly enabled.
8050
8051 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8052 @end deffn
8053
8054 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8055 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8056 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8057 @itemize @minus
8058 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8059 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8060 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8061 @end itemize
8062 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8063 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8064 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8065 the peripherals.
8066 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @section Intel Architecture
8070
8071 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8072 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8073 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8074 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8075 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8076 @itemize
8077 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8078 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8079 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8080 @end itemize
8081
8082 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8083 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8084 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8085
8086 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8087 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8091 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8095 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8099 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8103 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8107 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8108 @end deffn
8109
8110 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8111
8112 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8113 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8114
8115 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8116 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8117 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8118 @end deffn
8119 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8120 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8121
8122 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8123
8124 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8125 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8126 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8127 @end deffn
8128
8129 @subsection Registers commands
8130 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8131 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8132 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8133
8134 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8135
8136 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8137 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8138 and "timer" groups.
8139
8140 @emph{example:}
8141 @example
8142 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8143 @end example
8144
8145
8146 @end deffn
8147 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8148 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8149
8150 @emph{group} can be "system",
8151 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8152 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8153 @end deffn
8154
8155 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8156 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8157 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8158 @cindex tracing
8159 @cindex libdcc
8160 @cindex DCC
8161 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8162 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8163 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8164 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8165
8166 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8167 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8168 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8169 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8170 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8171 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8172
8173 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8174 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8175 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8176 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8177 The target being debugged may
8178 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8179 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8180 each supported by a command:
8181
8182 @itemize
8183 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8184 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8185 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8186 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8187
8188 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8189 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8190 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8191
8192 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8193 and then displayed at any time.
8194 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8195
8196 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8197 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8198 @end itemize
8199
8200 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8201 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8202 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8203 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8204 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8205 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8206 does the same thing.
8207
8208 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8209 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8210 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8211 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8212 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8213
8214 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8215 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8216 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8220 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8221 in the order they triggered.
8222 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8223 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8224 history records.
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8228 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8229 they have been triggered.
8230 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8231 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8232 and associates it with that identifier.
8233
8234 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8235 are not related except by this command.
8236 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8237 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8238 @end deffn
8239
8240
8241 @node JTAG Commands
8242 @chapter JTAG Commands
8243 @cindex JTAG Commands
8244 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8245 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8246 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8247 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8248 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8249
8250 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8251 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8252
8253 @itemize @bullet
8254 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8255 devices such as a CPUs.
8256 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8257 standard state machine (in parallel)
8258 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8259 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8260 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8261 while the reading previous ones.
8262 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8263 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8264 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8265 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8266 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8267 registers.
8268 @end itemize
8269
8270 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8271
8272 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8273 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8274 the order of TAP state transitions.
8275 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8276 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8277 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8278 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8279 these commands are not available.
8280
8281 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8282 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8283 that specify the entire register.
8284 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8285 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8286 The return value holds the original value of each
8287 of those fields.
8288
8289 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8290 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8291 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8292 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8293 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8294
8295 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8296 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8297
8298 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8299 in that state.
8300 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8301 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8302 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8303
8304 @quotation Warning
8305 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8306 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8307 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8308 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8309 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8310 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8311 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8312 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8313 @end quotation
8314 @end deffn
8315
8316 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8317 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8318 This may be used for performance tuning.
8319
8320 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8321 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8322 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8323 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8324 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8325 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8329 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8330 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8331 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8332 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8333 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8334
8335 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8336 in that state.
8337 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8338 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8339 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8340
8341 @quotation Note
8342 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8343 register values, unlike data register values.
8344 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8345 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8346 @end quotation
8347 @end deffn
8348
8349 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8350 Set values of reset signals.
8351 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8352 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8353 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8354 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8355 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8356 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8357 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8358
8359 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8360 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8361 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8362 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8363 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8364 instead of the TRST signal.
8365 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8366 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8367 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8368 with handlers for that event.
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8372 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8373 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8374 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8375 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8376 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8377 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8378 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8379 The final state must also be stable.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8383 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8384 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8385 Instructions often need some time
8386 to execute before they take effect.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8390 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8391
8392 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8393 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8394 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8395 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8396 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8397 @end deffn
8398
8399 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8400 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8401 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8402 must also be enabled.
8403 Default is enabled.
8404 @end deffn
8405
8406 @section TAP state names
8407 @cindex TAP state names
8408
8409 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8410 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8411 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8412 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8413
8414 @itemize @bullet
8415 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8416 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8417 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8418 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8419 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8420 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8421 through the data register
8422 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8423 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8424 for update or more shifting
8425 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8426 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8427 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8428 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8429 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8430 through the instruction register
8431 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8432 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8433 for update or more shifting
8434 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8435 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8436 @end itemize
8437
8438 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8439 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8440 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8441 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8442
8443 @itemize @bullet
8444 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8445 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8446 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8447 may not be as expected.
8448 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8449 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8450 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8451 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8452 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8453 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8454 @end itemize
8455
8456 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8457 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8458
8459 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8460 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8461 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8462 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8463
8464 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8465 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8466 @cindex SVF
8467
8468 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8469 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8470 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8471 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8472
8473 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8474 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8475 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8476 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8477 each command is logged before it is executed.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8481 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8482 @cindex XSVF
8483
8484 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8485 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8486 Xilinx devices.
8487 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8488 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8489
8490 @quotation Important
8491 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8492 @end quotation
8493
8494 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8495 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8496 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8497 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8498 that TAP.
8499 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8500 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8501 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8502 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8506 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8507 after building the software.
8508 You may find them useful:
8509
8510 @itemize
8511 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8512 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8513 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8514 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8515 @end itemize
8516
8517 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8518 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8519 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8520 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8521 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8522 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8523 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8524
8525
8526 @node Utility Commands
8527 @chapter Utility Commands
8528 @cindex Utility Commands
8529
8530 @section RAM testing
8531 @cindex RAM testing
8532
8533 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8534 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8535 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8536 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8537 hardware problems.
8538
8539 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8540 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8541 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8542 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8543
8544 Load the memory testing functions with
8545
8546 @example
8547 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8548 @end example
8549
8550 to get access to the following facilities:
8551
8552 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8553 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8554 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8558 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8559 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8560 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8561 @end deffn
8562
8563 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8564 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8565 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8566 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8570 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8571 @end deffn
8572
8573 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8574 @cindex Firmware recovery
8575
8576 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8577 devices recovery with JTAG.
8578
8579 For quickstart instructions run:
8580 @example
8581 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8582 @end example
8583
8584 @node TFTP
8585 @chapter TFTP
8586 @cindex TFTP
8587 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8588 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8589
8590 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8591 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8592 server (tftpd). For example,
8593
8594 @example
8595 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8596 @end example
8597
8598 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8599 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8600
8601 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8602 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8603 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8604 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8605
8606 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8607 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8608 @cindex GDB
8609 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8610 to debug remote targets.
8611 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8612
8613 @itemize
8614 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8615 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8616 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8617 as shown in this chapter.
8618 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8619 that also will probably need to be configured.
8620 @end itemize
8621
8622 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8623 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8624 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8625 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8626 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8627 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8628
8629 @section Connecting to GDB
8630 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8631 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8632 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8633 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8634 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8635
8636 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8637
8638 @enumerate
8639 @item
8640 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8641 @example
8642 target remote localhost:3333
8643 @end example
8644 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8645
8646 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8647 @example
8648 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8649 @end example
8650 @item
8651 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8652 @example
8653 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8654 @end example
8655 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8656 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8657 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8658 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8659 @end enumerate
8660
8661 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8662 GDB command line.
8663
8664 @section Sample GDB session startup
8665
8666 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8667 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8668 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8669 small ARM program.
8670 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8671 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8672
8673 @example
8674 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8675 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8676 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8677 ...
8678 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8679 ...
8680 (gdb) load
8681 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8682 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8683 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8684 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8685 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8686 (gdb) continue
8687 Continuing.
8688 ...
8689 @end example
8690
8691 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8692 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8693 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8694 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8695
8696 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8697
8698 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8699 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8700 packet size and the device's memory map.
8701 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8702 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8703 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8704
8705 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8706 You may need to set those up by hand.
8707 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8708 something like:
8709
8710 @example
8711 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8712 @end example
8713
8714 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8715
8716 @example
8717 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8718 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8719 @end example
8720
8721 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8722 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8723 do not have such restrictions.
8724
8725 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8726 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8727 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8728
8729 @example
8730 define hook-step
8731 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8732 end
8733 define hookpost-step
8734 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8735 end
8736 @end example
8737
8738 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8739 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8740 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8741 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8742
8743 @section Programming using GDB
8744 @cindex Programming using GDB
8745 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8746
8747 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8748 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8749 @example
8750 gdb_memory_map disable
8751 @end example
8752 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8753 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8754 working area.
8755
8756 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8757 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8758 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8759 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8760
8761 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8762 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8763
8764 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8765 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8766 @example
8767 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8768 @end example
8769
8770 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8771 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8772
8773 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8774 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8775 will be used.
8776
8777 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8778 script can be executed:
8779 @example
8780 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8781 @end example
8782
8783 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8784 can be used.
8785 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8786 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8787 @cindex SMP
8788 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8789 @itemize @bullet
8790 @item j - smp status request
8791 @item J - smp set request
8792 @end itemize
8793
8794 OpenOCD implements :
8795 @itemize @bullet
8796 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8797 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8798 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8799 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8800 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8801 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8802 @end itemize
8803
8804 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8805 @itemize @bullet
8806 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8807 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8808 @example
8809 set $_core 1
8810 #Jc01 packet is sent
8811 print $_core
8812 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8813 @end example
8814
8815 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8816 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8817
8818 @example
8819 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8820 define toggle0
8821 maint packet Jc0
8822 continue
8823 main packet Jc-1
8824 end
8825 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8826 define toggle1
8827 maint packet Jc1
8828 continue
8829 main packet Jc-1
8830 end
8831 @end example
8832 @end itemize
8833
8834 @section RTOS Support
8835 @cindex RTOS Support
8836 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8837
8838 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8839 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8840
8841 @* An example setup is below:
8842
8843 @example
8844 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8845 @end example
8846
8847 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8848
8849 Currently supported rtos's include:
8850 @itemize @bullet
8851 @item @option{eCos}
8852 @item @option{ThreadX}
8853 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8854 @item @option{linux}
8855 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8856 @item @option{embKernel}
8857 @item @option{mqx}
8858 @end itemize
8859
8860 @quotation Note
8861 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8862 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8863 @end quotation
8864
8865 @table @code
8866 @item eCos symbols
8867 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8868 @item ThreadX symbols
8869 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8870 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8871 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8872 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8873 @tex
8874 \begingroup
8875 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8876 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8877 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8878 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8879 \par
8880 \endgroup
8881 @end tex
8882 @item linux symbols
8883 init_task.
8884 @item ChibiOS symbols
8885 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8886 @item embKernel symbols
8887 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8888 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8889 @item mqx symbols
8890 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8891 @end table
8892
8893 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8894 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8895
8896 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8897 along with the project:
8898
8899 @table @code
8900 @item FreeRTOS
8901 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8902 @end table
8903
8904 @node Tcl Scripting API
8905 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8906 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8907 @cindex Tcl scripts
8908 @section API rules
8909
8910 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8911 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8912 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8913
8914 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8915 pair list and lists.
8916
8917 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8918 list.
8919
8920 @example
8921 > set foo(me) Duane
8922 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8923 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8924 > set foo(duck) Donald
8925 @end example
8926
8927 If one does this:
8928
8929 @example
8930 > set foo
8931 @end example
8932
8933 The result is:
8934
8935 @example
8936 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8937 @end example
8938
8939 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8940
8941 @verbatim
8942 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8943 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8944 }
8945 @end verbatim
8946
8947 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8948 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8949
8950 @section Internal low-level Commands
8951
8952 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8953 invoke directly.
8954
8955 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8956 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8957 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8958
8959 @itemize @bullet
8960 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8961
8962 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8963 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8964
8965 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8966 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8967
8968 Return information about the flash banks
8969
8970 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8971
8972 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8973 its execution. Example:
8974
8975 @example
8976 > capture "reset init"
8977 @end example
8978
8979 @end itemize
8980
8981 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8982 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8983 called "flash_banks".
8984
8985 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8986
8987 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8988 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8989 holds one of the following values:
8990
8991 @itemize @bullet
8992 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8993 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8994 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8995 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8996 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8997 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8998 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8999 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9000 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9001 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9002 @end itemize
9003
9004 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9005
9006 @quotation Note
9007 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9008 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9009 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9010 is jim, not real tcl).
9011 @end quotation
9012
9013 @section Tcl RPC server
9014 @cindex RPC
9015
9016 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9017 commands and receive the results.
9018
9019 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9020 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9021 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9022 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9023 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9024
9025 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9026 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9027 @command{capture} command.
9028
9029 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9030
9031 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9032 @cindex RPC Notifications
9033
9034 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9035 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9036
9037 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9038 in the following format.
9039
9040 @verbatim
9041 type target_event event [event-name]
9042 type target_state state [state-name]
9043 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9044 @end verbatim
9045
9046 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9047 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9048 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9049 Defaults to off.
9050
9051 @end deffn
9052
9053 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9054 @cindex RPC trace output
9055
9056 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9057 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9058
9059 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9060
9061 @verbatim
9062 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9063 @end verbatim
9064
9065 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9066 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9067 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9068 Defaults to off.
9069
9070 See an example application here:
9071 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9072
9073 @end deffn
9074
9075 @node FAQ
9076 @chapter FAQ
9077 @cindex faq
9078 @enumerate
9079 @anchor{faqrtck}
9080 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9081 @cindex RTCK
9082 @cindex adaptive clocking
9083 @*
9084
9085 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9086 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9087 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9088 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9089
9090 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9091 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9092 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9093 @enumerate
9094 @item
9095 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9096 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9097 @item
9098 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9099 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9100 @end enumerate
9101
9102 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9103 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9104 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9105 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9106 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9107 power).
9108
9109 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9110 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9111 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9112 ARM926 scenario).
9113 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9114 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9115 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9116
9117 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9118 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9119 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9120 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9121
9122 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9123
9124 In order to make use of this,
9125 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9126 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9127
9128 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9129 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9130 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9131 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9132 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9133
9134 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9135 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9136 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9137 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9138
9139 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9140 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9141 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9142 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9143 with a CPLD.
9144 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9145 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9146 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9147 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9148 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9149 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9150
9151 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9152
9153 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9154
9155 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9156 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9157 depending on the chips on your board.
9158 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9159 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9160 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9161
9162 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9163 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9164 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9165
9166 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9167 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9168 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9169 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9170
9171 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9172 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9173 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9174 this way.
9175
9176 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9177 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9178 clock rate.
9179 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9180 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9181 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9182
9183 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9184
9185 @example
9186 # Example: 1.234MHz
9187 adapter_khz 1234
9188 @end example
9189
9190
9191 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9192
9193 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9194 around Windows filenames.
9195
9196 @example
9197 > echo \a
9198
9199 > echo @{\a@}
9200 \a
9201 > echo "\a"
9202
9203 >
9204 @end example
9205
9206
9207 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9208
9209 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9210 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9211 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9212
9213 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9214 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9215 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9216
9217 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9218 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9219 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9220
9221 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9222
9223 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9224 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9225 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9226 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9227
9228 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9229 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9230 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9231
9232 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9233 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9234
9235 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9236 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9237 memory read caused data abort".
9238
9239 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9240 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9241 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9242 be done, feel free to add this here.
9243
9244 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9245 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9246 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9247 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9248 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9249 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9250 gracefully stops.
9251
9252 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9253 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9254 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9255
9256 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9257 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9258 bytes. Painful...
9259
9260
9261 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9262 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9263
9264 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9265 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9266 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9267 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9268 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9269 reset, everything else should work fine.
9270
9271 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9272 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9273 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9274 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9275
9276 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9277 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9278 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9279 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9280
9281 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9282
9283 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9284 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9285 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9286 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9287
9288 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9289 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9290 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9291 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9292
9293 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9294 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9295 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9296
9297 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9298 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9299
9300 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9301 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9302 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9303 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9304 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9305 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9306 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9307 clock frequency?
9308
9309 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9310 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9311 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9312 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9313 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9314
9315 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9316
9317 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9318 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9319 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9320 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9321 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9322 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9323 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9324
9325 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9326
9327 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9328 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9329 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9330 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9331
9332 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9333 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9334 particular order?
9335
9336 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9337 the same order used by the hardware.
9338
9339 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9340 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9341 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9342 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9343 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9344 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9345
9346 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9347 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9348 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9349 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9350
9351 @itemize @bullet
9352 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9353 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9354 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9355 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9356 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9357 @end itemize
9358
9359 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9360
9361 @itemize @bullet
9362 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9363 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9364 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9365 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9366 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9367 @end itemize
9368
9369
9370 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9371 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9372 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9373
9374 TODO.
9375
9376 @end enumerate
9377
9378 @node Tcl Crash Course
9379 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9380 @cindex Tcl
9381
9382 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9383 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9384 how the Tcl scripts work.
9385
9386 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9387 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9388 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9389 OpenOCD.
9390
9391 @section Tcl Rule #1
9392 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9393 @enumerate
9394 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9395 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9396 @end enumerate
9397
9398 The Tcl equal is this:
9399
9400 @enumerate
9401 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9402 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9403 @end enumerate
9404
9405 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9406 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9407
9408 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9409 There is a second pair of rules.
9410 @enumerate
9411 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9412 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9413 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9414 in Tcl.
9415 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9416 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9417 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9418 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9419 @end enumerate
9420
9421 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9422 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9423 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9424 Everything is a string}
9425
9426 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9427 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9428 difference is subtle.
9429 @enumerate
9430 @item Parse Time
9431 @item Evaluation Time
9432 @end enumerate
9433
9434 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9435 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9436 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9437
9438 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9439 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9440 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9441 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9442
9443 @itemize @bullet
9444 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9445 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9446 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9447 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9448 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9449 @example
9450 # bash example
9451 X=`date`
9452 echo "The Date is: $X"
9453 # Tcl example
9454 set X [date]
9455 puts "The Date is: $X"
9456 @end example
9457 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9458 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9459 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9460 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9461 is a string}
9462 @example
9463 set x "Dinner"
9464 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9465 @end example
9466 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9467 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9468 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9469 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9470 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9471 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9472 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9473 @end itemize
9474
9475 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9476
9477 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9478
9479 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9480
9481 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9482 the normal way.
9483
9484 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9485 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9486 line is immedatly executed.
9487
9488 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9489 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9490
9491 @subsection Command Execution
9492
9493 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9494 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9495 control flow operators.
9496
9497 Commands are executed like this:
9498
9499 @enumerate
9500 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9501 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9502 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9503 @end enumerate
9504
9505 It sort of works like this:
9506 @example
9507 for(;;)@{
9508 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9509
9510 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9511
9512 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9513 @}
9514 @end example
9515
9516 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9517 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9518 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9519 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9520 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9521 ``LookupCommand()''
9522
9523 @subsection The FOR command
9524
9525 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9526 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9527 command just like any other command.
9528
9529 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9530 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9531 are:
9532
9533 @enumerate 0
9534 @item The ascii text 'for'
9535 @item The start text
9536 @item The test expression
9537 @item The next text
9538 @item The body text
9539 @end enumerate
9540
9541 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9542 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9543 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9544 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9545
9546 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9547 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9548
9549 @example
9550 int
9551 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9552 int *argc,
9553 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9554 @end example
9555
9556 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9557 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9558 still operates in the same basic way.
9559
9560 @subsection FOR command implementation
9561
9562 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9563 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9564
9565 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9566
9567 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9568
9569 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9570 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9571 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9572
9573 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9574 expression and returns a value.
9575
9576 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9577 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9578 @example
9579 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9580
9581 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9582
9583 int
9584 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9585 int argc,
9586 char **argv )
9587 @{
9588 if( argc != 5 )@{
9589 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9590 return ERROR;
9591 @}
9592
9593 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9594
9595 // Execute the start statement.
9596 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9597
9598 // Top of loop test
9599 for(;;)@{
9600 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9601 if( i == 0 )
9602 break;
9603
9604 // Execute the body
9605 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9606
9607 // Execute the LOOP part
9608 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9609 @}
9610
9611 // Return no error
9612 SetResult( interp, "" );
9613 return SUCCESS;
9614 @}
9615 @end example
9616
9617 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9618 in the same basic way.
9619
9620 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9621
9622 @subsection source and find commands
9623 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9624 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9625 @*Remember the parsing rules
9626 @enumerate
9627 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9628 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9629 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9630 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9631 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9632 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9633 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9634 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9635 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9636 @end enumerate
9637 @subsection format command
9638 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9639 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9640 @b{sprintf()}.
9641 @b{Example}
9642 @example
9643 set x 6
9644 set y 7
9645 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9646 @end example
9647 @enumerate
9648 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9649 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9650 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9651 @* Refer to Rule #1
9652 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9653 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9654 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9655 @end enumerate
9656 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9657 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9658 @example
9659 #1 Good
9660 proc someproc @{@} @{
9661 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9662 @}
9663 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9664 #2 Good - no variables
9665 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9666 #3 Good Curly Braces
9667 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9668 puts "Time: [date]"
9669 @}
9670 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9671 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9672 @end example
9673 @enumerate
9674 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9675 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9676 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9677 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9678 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9679 command.
9680 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9681 @*There are 4 examples:
9682 @enumerate
9683 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9684 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9685 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9686 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9687 @end enumerate
9688
9689 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9690 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9691 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9692
9693 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9694 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9695 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9696 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9697 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9698 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9699 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9700 @end enumerate
9701 @subsection Global Variables
9702 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9703 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9704 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9705 @example
9706 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9707 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9708 global x #Global variable X
9709 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9710 @}
9711 @end example
9712 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9713 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9714 @example
9715 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9716 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9717 # Create var name
9718 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9719 # Make it a global
9720 global $vn
9721 # Set it.
9722 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9723 @}
9724 @end example
9725 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9726 @example
9727 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9728 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9729 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9730 @}
9731 @end example
9732
9733 @include fdl.texi
9734
9735 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9736 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9737 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9738 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9739 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9740 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9741
9742 @printindex cp
9743
9744 @node Command and Driver Index
9745 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9746 @printindex fn
9747
9748 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)